1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2 @c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
5 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
8 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9 @cindex machine description macros
10 @cindex target description macros
11 @cindex macros, target description
12 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
14 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
29 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59 * Misc:: Everything else.
62 @node Target Structure
63 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
65 @cindex target functions
67 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
77 #include "target-def.h"
79 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
81 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
84 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
88 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92 @code{targetm} structure.
94 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
97 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
98 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
103 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
105 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
107 @c prevent bad page break with this line
108 You can control the compilation driver.
110 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
111 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
112 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
114 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
115 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
116 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
117 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
118 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
119 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
121 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
122 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
123 that the other specs are easier to write.
125 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
128 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
129 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
130 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
131 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
132 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
134 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
135 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
136 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
137 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
138 everywhere it occurs.
140 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
141 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
142 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
144 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
148 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
149 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
150 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
152 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
155 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
156 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
157 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
158 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
162 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
163 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
165 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
166 for GCC to pass to front ends.
168 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
172 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
174 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
176 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
177 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
178 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
179 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
183 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
184 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
185 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
186 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
188 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
191 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
192 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
193 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
194 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
197 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
200 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
201 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
202 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
203 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
204 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
205 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
207 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
208 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
209 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
210 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
214 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
215 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
216 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
218 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
222 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
223 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
224 command given to the linker.
226 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
227 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
231 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
232 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
233 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
234 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
236 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
237 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
240 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
241 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
242 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
243 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
244 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
245 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
246 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
247 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
248 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
249 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
252 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
253 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
254 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
255 generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
256 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
257 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
261 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
262 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
263 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
264 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
267 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
268 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
269 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
270 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
272 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
273 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
277 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
278 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
279 the very end of the command given to the linker.
281 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
284 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
285 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
286 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
287 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
288 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
289 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
290 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
291 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
294 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
295 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
296 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
297 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
300 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
301 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
302 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
303 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
304 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
308 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
309 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
312 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
313 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
314 string constant that provides the specification.
316 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
318 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
319 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
320 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
323 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
324 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
325 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
328 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
331 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
332 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
334 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
337 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
341 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
342 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
343 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
344 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
346 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
347 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
350 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
351 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
354 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
359 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
360 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
361 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
362 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
365 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
366 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
367 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
370 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
371 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
372 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
373 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
374 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
375 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
376 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
377 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
380 @defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
381 A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
382 directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
383 removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
386 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
387 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
388 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
389 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
390 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
392 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
393 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
394 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
395 @xref{Target Fragment}.
398 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
399 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
400 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
401 indicates an absolute file name.
404 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
405 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
406 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
407 when the compiler is built as a cross
408 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
409 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
412 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
413 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
414 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
415 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
416 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
417 is built as a cross compiler.
420 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
421 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
422 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
423 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
424 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
425 is built as a cross compiler.
428 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
429 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
430 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
431 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
432 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
433 is built as a cross compiler.
436 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
437 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
438 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
439 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
442 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
443 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
444 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
448 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
449 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
450 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
451 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
452 initialize the necessary environment variables.
455 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
456 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
457 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
458 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
459 comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
461 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
465 @defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
466 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
467 system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
468 directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
469 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
471 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
475 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
476 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
477 standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
478 try when searching for header files.
480 Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
481 @file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
484 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
485 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
486 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
487 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
490 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
491 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
492 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
493 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
494 @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
495 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
496 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
497 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
498 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
500 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
501 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
502 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
503 for C++-only directories,
504 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
505 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
506 the array with a null element.
508 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
509 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
510 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
511 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
513 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
516 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
518 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
519 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
520 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
527 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
531 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
534 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
535 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
536 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
539 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
542 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
543 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
546 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
549 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
552 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
556 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
560 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
563 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
564 value based on the installed toolchain location.
567 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
568 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
571 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
572 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
575 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
578 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
582 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
583 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
586 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
587 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
590 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
591 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
592 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
595 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
596 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
600 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
601 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
605 @node Run-time Target
606 @section Run-time Target Specification
607 @cindex run-time target specification
608 @cindex predefined macros
609 @cindex target specifications
611 @c prevent bad page break with this line
612 Here are run-time target specifications.
614 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
615 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
616 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
617 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
618 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
619 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
620 finished command line option processing your code can use those
623 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
624 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
625 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
626 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
628 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
629 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
630 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
631 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
632 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
633 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
634 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
635 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
636 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
637 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
639 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
640 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
641 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
642 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
643 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
644 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
645 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
646 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
650 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
651 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
652 and is used for the target operating system instead.
655 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
656 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
657 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
658 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
662 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
663 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
664 any target-specific headers.
667 @deftypevr {Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
668 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
669 Its default setting is 0.
672 @cindex optional hardware or system features
673 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
675 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, unsigned int @var{loc})
676 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
677 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
678 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
679 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
680 definition does nothing but return true.
682 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
683 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
684 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
685 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
689 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
690 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
691 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
692 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
693 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
694 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
695 default definition does nothing but return false.
697 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
698 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
699 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
700 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
703 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
704 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
707 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
708 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
711 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
712 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
715 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
716 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
717 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
718 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
719 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
720 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
721 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
722 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
725 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
726 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
727 but is only used in the C
728 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
729 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
733 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
734 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
735 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
736 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
737 options are processed once
738 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
739 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
740 options passed explicitly.
742 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
743 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
744 @code{optimize} attribute.
747 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
748 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
751 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
752 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
755 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_HELP (void)
756 This hook is called in response to the user invoking
757 @option{--target-help} on the command line. It gives the target a
758 chance to display extra information on the target specific command
759 line options found in its @file{.opt} file.
762 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
763 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
764 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
765 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
766 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
767 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
769 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
770 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
771 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
772 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
773 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
774 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
775 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
777 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
781 @node Per-Function Data
782 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
783 @cindex per-function data
784 @cindex data structures
786 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
787 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
788 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
789 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
790 when another one comes along.
792 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
793 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
794 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
795 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
796 to their own specific data.
798 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
799 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
800 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
801 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
803 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
804 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
805 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
806 function, for level 0.
808 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
809 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
810 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
811 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
812 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
813 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
814 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
815 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
818 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
819 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
820 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
821 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
822 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
825 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
826 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
827 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
828 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
829 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
830 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
832 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
833 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
834 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
838 @section Storage Layout
839 @cindex storage layout
841 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
842 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
843 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
844 @xref{Run-time Target}.
846 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
847 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
848 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
849 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
850 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
851 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
852 macro need not be a constant.
854 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
855 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
858 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
859 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
860 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
863 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
864 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
865 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
866 memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
867 order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
868 macro need not be a constant.
871 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
872 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
873 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
874 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
875 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
877 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
881 @defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
882 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
883 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
886 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
887 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
888 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
891 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
892 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
893 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
894 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
897 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
898 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
899 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
902 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
903 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
904 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
905 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
909 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
910 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
911 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
912 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
915 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
916 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
917 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
918 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
919 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
920 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
921 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
923 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
924 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
927 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
928 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
929 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
930 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
933 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
934 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
935 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
936 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
937 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
940 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
941 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
942 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
943 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
944 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
945 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
947 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
950 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
951 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
952 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
953 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
954 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
957 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
958 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
959 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
960 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
961 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
962 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
963 the signedness may be different.
965 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
967 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
968 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
969 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
972 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
973 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
974 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
975 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
979 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
980 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
981 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
982 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
983 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
984 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
987 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
988 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
989 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
990 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
991 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
992 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
995 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
996 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
997 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
998 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1001 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1002 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1005 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1006 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1007 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1008 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1011 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1012 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1013 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1016 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1017 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1018 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1021 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1022 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1023 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1024 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1025 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1028 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1029 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1030 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1031 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1032 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1035 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1036 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1037 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1038 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1039 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1040 field alignment has not been set by the
1041 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1044 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1045 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1046 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1048 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1050 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1051 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1052 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1053 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1056 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1057 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1058 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1059 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1060 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1062 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1063 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1064 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1065 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1066 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1069 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1070 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1071 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1072 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1073 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1075 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1078 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1079 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1080 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1081 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1084 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1085 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1086 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1087 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1088 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1091 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1093 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1094 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1095 constants can be done inline.
1098 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1099 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1100 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1101 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1102 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1104 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1106 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1107 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1109 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1112 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1113 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1114 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1115 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1116 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1119 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1120 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1123 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1124 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1126 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1129 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1130 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1131 variable @var{decl}.
1133 If this macro is not defined, then
1134 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1137 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1138 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1140 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1143 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1144 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1145 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1146 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1148 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1151 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1152 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1153 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1155 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1158 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1159 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1160 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1162 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1163 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1166 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1167 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1168 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1169 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1172 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1173 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1174 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1176 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1177 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1178 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1179 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1180 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1182 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1183 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1184 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1185 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1187 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1190 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1191 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1193 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1194 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1195 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1196 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1198 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1199 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1200 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1202 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1203 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1204 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1206 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1207 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1208 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1227 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1228 sizeof (struct foo1));
1229 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1230 sizeof (struct foo2));
1235 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1236 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1239 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1240 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1241 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1244 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1245 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1246 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1247 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1248 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1251 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1252 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1253 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1254 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1256 The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1259 @defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1260 Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1263 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1264 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1265 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1266 retain the field's mode.
1268 Normally, this is not needed.
1271 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1272 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1273 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1274 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1277 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1278 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1281 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1282 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1283 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1284 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1285 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1286 (DImode)} is assumed.
1289 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1290 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1291 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1292 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1293 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1294 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1295 having its mode specified.
1297 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1298 would most commonly define this macro if the
1299 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1303 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1304 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1305 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1306 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1308 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1309 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1310 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1313 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1314 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1315 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1316 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1320 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1321 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1322 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1323 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1327 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1328 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1329 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1332 @defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1333 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1334 mode is towards zero.
1336 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1337 floating-point arithmetic.
1339 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1342 @defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1343 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1344 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1345 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1347 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1348 floating-point arithmetic.
1350 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1353 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1354 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1355 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1356 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1357 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1358 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1359 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1360 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1361 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1362 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1363 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1364 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1366 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1367 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1368 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1369 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1370 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1371 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1372 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1374 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1375 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1376 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1377 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1378 may affect its placement.
1381 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1382 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1385 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1386 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1389 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1390 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1391 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1392 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1393 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1394 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1398 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1399 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1400 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1403 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1404 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1405 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1406 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1407 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1408 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1409 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1410 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1411 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1414 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1415 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1416 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1417 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1418 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1419 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1420 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1421 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1422 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1423 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1424 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1425 spaces in your string.
1427 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1428 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1429 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1432 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1433 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1438 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1440 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1441 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1442 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1443 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1445 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1446 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1447 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1450 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1451 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1452 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1453 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1457 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1458 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1459 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1462 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1463 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1464 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1465 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1466 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1467 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1470 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1471 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1472 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1473 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1474 macro must be at least 64.
1477 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1478 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1479 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1480 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1483 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1484 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1485 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1486 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1489 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1490 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1491 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1494 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1495 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1496 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1500 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1501 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1502 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1506 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1507 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1508 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1509 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1512 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1513 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1514 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1515 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1518 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1519 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1520 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1521 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1524 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1525 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1526 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1527 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1530 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1531 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1532 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1533 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1536 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1537 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1538 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1539 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1542 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1543 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1544 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1545 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1548 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1549 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1550 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1551 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1554 @defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1555 Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1556 if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1557 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1558 default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1561 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1562 Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1563 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1564 @code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1565 anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1566 or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1570 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1571 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1572 @code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1573 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1574 is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1577 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1578 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1579 @code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1580 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1581 is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1584 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1585 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1586 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1587 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1588 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1589 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1590 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1597 Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1598 @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1599 if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1600 @code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1601 for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1602 @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1603 @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1604 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1607 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1608 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1609 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1610 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1611 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1614 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1615 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1616 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1617 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1618 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1622 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1623 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1624 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1625 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1626 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1629 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1630 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1631 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1632 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1633 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1635 The default is to return false.
1639 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1640 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1641 contents of the string.
1643 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1644 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1645 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1646 of the data type names defined in the function
1647 @code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1648 omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1651 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1655 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1656 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1657 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1658 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1659 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1661 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1665 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1666 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1667 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1670 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1673 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1674 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1675 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1680 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1681 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1682 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1683 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1686 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1690 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1691 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1692 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1693 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1695 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1696 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1697 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1700 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1701 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1702 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1703 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1704 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1706 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1707 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1708 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1712 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1718 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1719 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1720 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1721 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1722 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1723 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1724 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1725 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1726 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1727 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1728 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1729 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1730 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1731 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1732 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1733 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1734 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1735 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1736 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1737 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1738 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1739 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1740 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1741 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1742 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1743 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1744 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1745 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1746 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1747 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1748 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1750 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1751 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1752 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1753 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1754 these macros are null pointers.
1757 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1758 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1765 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1772 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1773 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1774 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1775 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1776 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1777 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1778 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1779 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1781 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1782 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1783 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1784 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1785 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1786 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1787 architecture, you should define this macro to
1788 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1790 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1791 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1792 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1793 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1796 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1797 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1798 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1799 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1800 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1801 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1802 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1804 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1805 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1808 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1809 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1810 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1811 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1812 when special alignment is necessary. */
1815 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1816 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1817 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1818 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1819 of words in each data entry.
1823 @section Register Usage
1824 @cindex register usage
1826 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1827 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1829 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1830 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1831 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1832 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1833 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1836 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1837 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1838 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1839 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1840 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1843 @node Register Basics
1844 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1846 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1847 Registers have various characteristics.
1849 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1850 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1851 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1852 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1853 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1856 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1857 @cindex fixed register
1858 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1859 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1860 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1861 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1862 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1863 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1864 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1866 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1867 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1868 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1870 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1871 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1872 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1873 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1874 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1877 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1878 @cindex call-used register
1879 @cindex call-clobbered register
1880 @cindex call-saved register
1881 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1882 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1883 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1884 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1887 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1888 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1889 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1892 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1893 @cindex call-used register
1894 @cindex call-clobbered register
1895 @cindex call-saved register
1896 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1897 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1898 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1899 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1900 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1903 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1904 @cindex call-used register
1905 @cindex call-clobbered register
1906 @cindex call-saved register
1907 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1908 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1909 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1910 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1911 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1915 @findex call_used_regs
1918 @findex reg_class_contents
1919 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1920 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1921 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1922 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1923 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1924 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1925 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1926 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1927 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1928 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1929 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1930 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1931 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1932 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1933 command options have been applied.
1935 @cindex disabling certain registers
1936 @cindex controlling register usage
1937 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1938 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1939 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1940 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1941 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1942 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1943 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1945 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1946 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1947 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1948 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1951 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1952 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1953 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1954 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1955 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1959 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1960 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1961 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1962 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1963 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1967 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1968 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1969 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1970 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1971 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1976 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1977 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1980 @node Allocation Order
1981 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1982 @cindex order of register allocation
1983 @cindex register allocation order
1985 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1986 Registers are allocated in order.
1988 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1989 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1990 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1991 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1993 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1994 (all else being equal).
1996 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1997 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1998 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1999 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2000 the highest numbered allocable register first.
2003 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2004 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2005 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2007 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2008 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2009 register; and so on.
2011 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2012 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2014 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2017 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2018 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2019 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2020 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2021 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2022 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2026 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2027 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2028 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2029 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2030 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2031 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2032 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2033 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2035 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2038 @node Values in Registers
2039 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2041 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2042 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2043 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2045 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2046 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2047 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2048 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2049 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2050 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2052 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2053 definition of this macro is
2056 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2057 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2062 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2063 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2064 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2065 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2066 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2067 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2068 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2070 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2071 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2074 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2075 @code{subreg_get_info}
2076 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2077 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2078 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2079 registers and so not be representable.
2082 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2083 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2084 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2085 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2086 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2089 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2090 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2091 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2092 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2093 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2094 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2095 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2098 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2099 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2100 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2101 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2102 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2105 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2108 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2109 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2111 @cindex register pairs
2112 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2113 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2114 odd register numbers for such modes.
2116 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2117 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2118 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2119 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2121 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2122 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2123 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2124 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2125 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2126 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2129 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2130 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2131 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2132 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2133 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2134 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2136 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2137 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2138 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2139 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2140 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2141 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2142 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2143 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2144 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2146 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2147 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2148 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2149 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2150 constraints for those instructions.
2152 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2153 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2154 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2155 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2156 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2159 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2160 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2161 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2163 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2164 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2167 The default is always nonzero.
2170 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2171 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2172 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2174 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2175 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2176 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2177 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2178 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2179 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2181 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2182 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2186 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2187 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2188 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2190 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2191 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2193 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2196 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2197 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2198 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2199 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2202 @node Leaf Functions
2203 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2205 @cindex leaf functions
2206 @cindex functions, leaf
2207 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2208 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2209 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2210 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2213 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2214 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2215 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2216 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2217 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2220 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2221 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2222 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2225 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2226 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2227 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2230 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2231 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2232 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2233 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2236 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2237 the treatment of leaf functions.
2240 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2241 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2242 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2244 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2245 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2246 will cause the compiler to abort.
2248 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2249 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2253 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2254 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2255 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2256 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2257 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2258 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2259 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2260 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2261 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2262 functions which only use leaf registers.
2263 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2264 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2265 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2266 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2267 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2269 @node Stack Registers
2270 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2272 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2273 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2274 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2277 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2278 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2279 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2280 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2281 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2282 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2283 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2286 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2289 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2290 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2291 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2294 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2295 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2299 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2300 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2304 @node Register Classes
2305 @section Register Classes
2306 @cindex register class definitions
2307 @cindex class definitions, register
2309 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2310 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2311 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2312 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2314 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2315 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2316 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2320 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2321 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2322 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2323 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2325 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2326 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2327 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2328 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2329 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2332 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2333 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2335 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2336 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2337 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2338 them in operand constraints.
2340 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2341 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2342 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2343 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2344 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2345 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2346 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2348 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2349 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2350 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2353 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2354 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2355 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2356 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2357 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2359 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2360 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2361 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2362 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2363 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2364 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2365 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2366 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2367 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2369 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2370 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2371 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2372 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2373 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2374 tells how many classes there are.
2376 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2377 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2378 in many of the tables described below.
2381 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2382 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2385 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2389 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2390 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2391 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2394 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2395 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2396 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2397 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2398 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2400 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2401 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2402 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2403 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2404 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2405 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2409 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2410 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2411 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2412 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2416 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2417 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2418 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2419 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2422 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2423 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2424 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2425 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2426 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2429 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2430 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2431 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2432 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2433 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2436 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2437 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2438 base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2439 context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2440 the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2441 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2442 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2443 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2446 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2447 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2448 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2449 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2450 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2453 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2454 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2455 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2458 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2459 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2460 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2461 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2462 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2463 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2464 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2465 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2466 @code{address_operand}.
2469 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2470 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2471 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2472 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2473 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2474 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2475 than other base register uses.
2477 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2478 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2481 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2482 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2483 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2484 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2485 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2486 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2487 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2488 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2489 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2490 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2493 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2494 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2495 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2496 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2497 allocated such a hard register.
2499 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2500 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2501 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2502 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2503 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2504 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2505 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2506 only if neither labeling works.
2509 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2510 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2513 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2514 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2515 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2516 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2517 another, smaller class.
2519 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2521 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2522 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2523 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2524 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2525 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2527 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2528 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2529 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2530 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2531 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2532 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2533 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2534 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2535 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2536 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2537 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2539 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2540 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2541 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2542 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2543 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2544 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2547 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2548 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2549 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2550 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2551 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2555 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2558 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2559 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2560 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2561 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2562 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2564 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2565 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2566 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2567 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2568 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2569 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2570 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2571 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2572 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2573 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2574 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2576 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2577 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2578 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2579 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2580 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2581 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2584 @defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2585 Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2586 input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2587 @var{class}, unchanged.
2589 You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2590 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2593 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2594 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2597 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2600 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2601 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2604 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2605 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2606 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2607 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2610 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2611 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2613 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2616 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2617 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2620 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2621 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2622 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2623 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2624 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2625 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2626 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2627 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2628 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2629 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2630 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2631 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2632 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2634 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2635 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2636 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2637 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2638 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2639 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2640 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2641 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2642 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2643 of the scratch register(s).
2645 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2647 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2648 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2649 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2650 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2651 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2653 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2654 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2655 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2656 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2657 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2658 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2660 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2661 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2662 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2663 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2664 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2666 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2667 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2668 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2669 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2670 single-register-class
2671 @c [later: or memory]
2674 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2675 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2676 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2677 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2679 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2680 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2681 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2682 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2683 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2684 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2685 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2686 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2689 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2690 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2691 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2692 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2694 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2695 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2696 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2698 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2699 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2700 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2701 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2702 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2703 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2706 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2707 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2708 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2709 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2710 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2712 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2713 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2714 reload phase that it may
2715 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2716 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2717 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2718 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2719 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2720 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2722 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2723 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2724 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2725 class required. If the
2726 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2727 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2730 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2731 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2732 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2733 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2734 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2736 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2737 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2738 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2739 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2740 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2741 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2744 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2746 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2747 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2748 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2749 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2750 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2752 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2753 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2754 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2755 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2757 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2758 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2759 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2760 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2761 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2762 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2766 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2767 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2768 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2769 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2770 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2771 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2772 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2774 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2777 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2778 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2779 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2780 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2781 defined by this macro.
2783 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2784 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2787 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2788 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2789 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2790 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2791 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2792 same as that of @var{mode}.
2794 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2795 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2796 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2799 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2800 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2801 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2802 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2803 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2806 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2807 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2808 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2811 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2812 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2813 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2814 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2816 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2817 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2818 default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2819 if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2820 hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2821 @code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2822 @file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2823 register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2824 you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2825 the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2829 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2830 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2831 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2833 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2834 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2835 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2836 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2838 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2842 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2843 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2844 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2846 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2847 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2848 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2849 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2850 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2854 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2855 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2856 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2860 @node Old Constraints
2861 @section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2862 @cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2863 @cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2865 Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2866 of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2867 Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2868 it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2870 @defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2871 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2872 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2873 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2874 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2875 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2876 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2877 to handle specially.
2878 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2879 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2880 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2881 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2882 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2885 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2886 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2887 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2888 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2889 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2890 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2891 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2894 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2895 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2896 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2900 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2901 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2902 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2903 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2904 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2905 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2906 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2910 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2911 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2912 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2913 between different variants.
2916 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2917 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2918 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2919 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2921 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2922 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2923 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2924 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2926 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2927 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2928 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2929 between these kinds.
2932 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2933 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2934 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2935 between different variants.
2938 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2939 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2940 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2941 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2942 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2943 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2944 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2946 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2947 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2948 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2949 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2951 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2952 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2953 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2954 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2955 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2956 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2957 does not include r0 on the output.
2960 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2961 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2962 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2966 @defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2967 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2968 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2969 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2971 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2972 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2973 comprises a subset of all memory references including
2974 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2975 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2976 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2978 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2979 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2980 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2981 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2982 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2983 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2984 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2985 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2986 an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2989 @defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2990 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2991 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2992 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
2993 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
2995 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2996 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
2997 a subset of all memory addresses including
2998 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
2999 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3000 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3002 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3003 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3004 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3007 @node Stack and Calling
3008 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3009 @cindex calling conventions
3011 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3012 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3016 * Exception Handling::
3021 * Register Arguments::
3023 * Aggregate Return::
3028 * Stack Smashing Protection::
3032 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3033 @cindex stack frame layout
3034 @cindex frame layout
3036 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3037 Here is the basic stack layout.
3039 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3040 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3041 pointer to a smaller address.
3043 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3044 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3045 definition used does not matter.
3048 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3049 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3050 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3051 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3053 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3054 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3055 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3056 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3057 space for the next item on the stack.
3059 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3060 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3061 which is often wrong.
3064 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3065 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3066 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3069 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3070 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3071 addresses on the stack.
3074 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3075 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3077 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3078 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3079 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3080 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3081 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3082 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3085 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3086 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3087 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3089 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3090 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3091 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3092 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3095 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3096 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3097 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3098 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3100 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3101 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3104 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3105 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3106 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3109 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3110 the first argument's address.
3113 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3114 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3115 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3117 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3118 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3119 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3122 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3123 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3124 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3125 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3126 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3127 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3128 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3131 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3132 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3133 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3134 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3137 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3138 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3139 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3142 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3143 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3144 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3145 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3146 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3150 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3151 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3152 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3153 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3154 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3155 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3158 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3159 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3160 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3161 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3162 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3163 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3166 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3167 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3168 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3169 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3170 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3171 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3173 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3174 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3175 determine the return address of other frames.
3178 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3179 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3180 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3183 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3184 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3185 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3186 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3187 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3190 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3191 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3193 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3194 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3197 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3198 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3199 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3200 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3201 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3203 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3204 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3205 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3209 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3210 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3211 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3212 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3213 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3214 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3217 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3218 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3219 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3220 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3222 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3226 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3228 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3229 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3230 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3233 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3234 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3235 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3236 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3237 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3238 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3240 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3241 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3244 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3245 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3246 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3247 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3248 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3249 during virtual register instantiation.
3251 The default value for this macro is
3252 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3253 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3254 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3255 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3256 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3258 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3259 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3263 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3264 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3265 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3266 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3267 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3269 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3270 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3271 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3272 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3273 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3274 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3278 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3279 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3280 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3281 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3282 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3285 @node Exception Handling
3286 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3287 @cindex exception handling
3289 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3290 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3291 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3292 @var{N} registers are usable.
3294 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3295 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3296 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3297 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3298 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3300 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3301 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3304 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3305 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3306 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3307 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3308 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3310 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3311 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3313 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3314 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3315 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3316 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3317 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3318 that provided by DWARF 2.
3321 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3322 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3323 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3324 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3326 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3327 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3328 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3329 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3330 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3331 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3334 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3335 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3336 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3338 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3339 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3342 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3343 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3344 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3345 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3346 using it to return to the exception handler.
3349 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3350 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3351 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3352 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3353 and so may be read-only.
3355 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3356 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3357 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3358 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3360 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3361 represented directly.
3364 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3365 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3366 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3367 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3368 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3370 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3371 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3372 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3376 @defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
3377 A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c. The file
3378 so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
3381 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3382 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3383 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3384 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3385 through signal frames.
3387 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3388 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3389 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3390 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3391 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3392 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3393 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3394 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3395 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3397 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3398 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3401 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3402 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3403 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3404 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3406 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3407 @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3408 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3409 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3410 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3411 be updated in @var{fs}.
3414 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3415 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3416 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3417 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3420 @node Stack Checking
3421 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3423 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3424 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3429 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3430 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3431 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3432 other special processing.
3435 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3436 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3437 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3438 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3439 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3440 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3444 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3445 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3448 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3449 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3450 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3451 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3453 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3454 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3455 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3456 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3457 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3458 value of this macro is zero.
3461 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3462 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3463 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3464 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3465 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3468 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3469 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3470 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3471 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3472 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3473 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3476 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3477 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3478 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3479 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3480 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3481 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3482 default value of this macro is zero.
3485 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3486 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3487 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3488 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3489 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3493 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3494 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3495 in the opposite case.
3497 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3498 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3499 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3500 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3501 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3502 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3503 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3506 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3507 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3508 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3509 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3510 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3511 use the default of four words.
3514 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3515 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3516 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3517 @option{-fstack-check}.
3518 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3519 normally not need to override that default.
3523 @node Frame Registers
3524 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3526 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3527 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3529 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3530 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3531 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3532 the hardware determines which register this is.
3535 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3536 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3537 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3538 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3539 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3542 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3543 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3544 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3545 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3546 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3547 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3548 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3549 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3550 used for the frame pointer.
3552 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3553 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3554 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3555 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3556 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3557 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3558 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3560 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3561 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3564 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3565 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3566 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3567 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3568 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3569 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3570 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3571 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3572 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3575 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3576 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3577 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3578 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3579 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3580 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3583 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3584 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3585 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3586 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3587 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3588 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3591 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3592 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3593 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3594 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3595 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3596 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3597 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3599 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3600 address from the stack.
3603 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3604 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3605 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3606 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3607 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3608 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3609 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3612 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3614 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3615 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3619 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3620 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3621 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3622 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3623 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3625 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3627 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3628 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3629 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3630 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3631 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3632 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3633 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3634 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3635 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3636 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3637 to refer to those items.
3640 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3641 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3642 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3643 DWARF2 exception handling.
3645 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3646 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3647 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3648 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3649 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3650 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3651 registers that are not call-saved.
3653 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3654 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3657 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3659 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3660 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3662 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3663 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3666 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3668 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3669 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3670 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3671 column number to use instead.
3673 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3676 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3678 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3679 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3680 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3681 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3682 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3686 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3688 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3689 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3690 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3691 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3692 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3697 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3699 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3700 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3702 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3703 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3704 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3705 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3707 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3708 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3709 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3710 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3711 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3714 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3715 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3716 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3717 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3720 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3721 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3722 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3724 Default return value is @code{false}.
3727 @findex get_frame_size
3728 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3729 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3730 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3731 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3732 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3733 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3735 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3736 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3737 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3738 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3741 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3742 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3743 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3744 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3745 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3747 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3748 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3750 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3751 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3752 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3753 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3754 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3756 In this case, you might specify:
3758 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3759 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3760 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3761 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3764 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3765 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3768 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3769 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3770 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3771 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3772 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3773 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3776 Default return value is @code{true}.
3779 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3780 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3781 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3782 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3786 @node Stack Arguments
3787 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3788 @cindex arguments on stack
3789 @cindex stack arguments
3791 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3792 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3793 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3795 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3796 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3797 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3798 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3799 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3800 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3804 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3806 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3807 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3808 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3809 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3812 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3813 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3814 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3815 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3816 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3819 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3820 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3821 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3823 On some machines, the definition
3826 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3830 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3831 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3832 alignment. Then the definition should be
3835 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3838 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3841 @findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3842 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3843 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3844 will be computed and placed into the variable
3845 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3846 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3847 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3849 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3853 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3854 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3855 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3858 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3859 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3860 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3861 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3864 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3865 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3868 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3869 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3871 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3872 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3873 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3874 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3875 if the function called is a library function.
3877 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3878 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3879 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3882 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3883 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3884 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3885 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3886 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3888 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3889 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3890 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3891 stack in its natural location.
3894 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3895 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3896 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3897 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3899 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3900 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3901 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3902 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3904 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3905 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3906 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3907 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3908 arguments (if known).
3910 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3911 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3912 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3913 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3914 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3915 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3917 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3918 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3919 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3921 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3922 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3923 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3924 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3925 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3926 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3927 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3928 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3929 number of arguments.
3932 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3933 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3934 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3935 when compiling a function call.
3937 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3938 have been accumulated.
3940 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3941 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3942 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3943 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3947 @node Register Arguments
3948 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3949 @cindex arguments in registers
3950 @cindex registers arguments
3952 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3953 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3956 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3957 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3958 register and if so, which register.
3960 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
3961 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3962 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3963 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3964 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3965 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3966 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3967 syntax error has previously occurred.
3969 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3970 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3973 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3974 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3975 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3976 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3977 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3978 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3979 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3980 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3981 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3982 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3983 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3984 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3985 argument is also stored on the stack.
3987 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3988 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3989 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3991 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3992 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3993 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3994 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3995 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3996 @var{named} is @code{false}.
3998 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3999 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4000 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4001 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4002 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4003 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4004 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4005 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4009 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4010 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4011 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4012 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4016 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4017 Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4018 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4019 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4022 For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4023 which the caller passes the value, and
4024 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4025 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4028 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4029 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4032 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4033 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4034 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4035 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4036 pushed on the stack.
4038 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4039 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4040 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4041 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4042 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4043 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4044 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4046 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4047 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4048 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4051 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4052 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4053 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4054 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4055 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4057 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4058 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4059 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4063 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4064 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4065 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4066 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4069 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4070 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4073 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4076 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4077 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4078 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4079 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4080 of bytes of argument so far.
4082 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4083 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4084 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4085 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4086 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4087 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4090 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4091 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4092 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4093 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4094 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4095 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4096 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4099 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4100 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4101 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4102 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4103 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4104 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4105 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4106 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4107 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4108 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4109 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4110 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4111 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4113 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4114 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4115 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4116 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4117 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4118 never both of them at once.
4121 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4122 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4123 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4124 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4125 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4126 0)} is used instead.
4129 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4130 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4131 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4132 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4134 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4135 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4136 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4137 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4138 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4139 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4142 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4143 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4144 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4145 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4146 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4147 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4149 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4150 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4151 used for arguments without any special help.
4154 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4155 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4156 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4157 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4158 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4162 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4163 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4164 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4165 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4166 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4168 The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
4169 multiple of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not
4172 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4173 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4174 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4175 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4178 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4179 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4180 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4181 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4182 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4183 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4186 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4187 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4188 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4189 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4190 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4191 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4192 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4193 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4197 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4198 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4199 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4200 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4203 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4204 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4205 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4206 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4207 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4208 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4212 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4213 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4214 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4215 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4216 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4217 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4218 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4221 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4225 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4226 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4227 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4230 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4231 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4232 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4233 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4234 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4236 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4237 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4239 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4240 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4241 macro to iterate through all types.
4244 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4245 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4247 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4250 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4251 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4252 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4256 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4257 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4258 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4259 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4260 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4263 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4264 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4265 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4266 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4269 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref_s *@var{ref})
4270 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4273 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4274 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4275 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4276 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4279 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4280 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4281 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4282 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4285 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4286 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4287 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4288 must have move patterns for this mode.
4291 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4292 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4293 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4294 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4295 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4297 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4298 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4299 has operations like:
4302 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4305 where the return type is defined as:
4308 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4314 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4315 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4316 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4319 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4320 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4321 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4322 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4323 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4324 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4327 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4328 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4329 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4330 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4333 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4334 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4335 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4336 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4337 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4338 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4339 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4340 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4341 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4343 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4344 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4345 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4346 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4347 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4348 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4351 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4352 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
4356 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4357 @cindex return values in registers
4358 @cindex values, returned by functions
4359 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4361 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4362 values---values that can fit in registers.
4364 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4366 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4367 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4368 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4369 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4370 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4371 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4372 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4373 a function returns a value.
4375 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4376 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4377 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4378 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4379 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4380 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4381 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4382 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4383 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4384 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4385 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4386 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4388 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4389 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4390 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4392 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4393 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4394 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4395 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4398 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4399 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4400 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4401 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4403 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4404 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4405 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4408 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4409 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4410 a new target instead.
4413 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4414 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4415 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4417 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4418 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4419 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4423 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4424 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4425 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4427 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4428 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4429 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4431 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4434 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4435 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4436 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4438 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4439 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4440 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4444 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4447 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4448 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4449 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4451 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4452 for a new target instead.
4455 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4456 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4457 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4459 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4460 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4461 recognized by this target hook.
4463 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4464 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4465 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4467 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4470 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4471 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4472 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4473 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4476 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4477 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4478 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4479 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4480 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4482 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4483 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4484 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4485 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4489 @node Aggregate Return
4490 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4491 @cindex aggregates as return values
4492 @cindex large return values
4493 @cindex returning aggregate values
4494 @cindex structure value address
4496 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4497 cases), the value is not returned according to
4498 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4499 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4500 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4503 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4506 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4507 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4508 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4509 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4510 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4513 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4514 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4515 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4516 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4517 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4518 values, and 0 otherwise.
4520 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4521 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4525 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4526 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4527 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4528 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4529 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4530 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4533 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4536 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4537 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4538 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4539 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4540 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4541 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4544 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4545 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4546 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4547 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4548 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4549 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4552 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4553 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4554 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4555 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4556 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4559 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4560 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4561 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4562 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4564 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4565 pass an address to the subroutine.
4567 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4568 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4571 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4572 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4575 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4576 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4580 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4582 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4583 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4584 must live across calls.
4586 @defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4587 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4588 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4589 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4590 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4592 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4593 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4596 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4597 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4598 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4599 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4600 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4601 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4604 @node Function Entry
4605 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4606 @cindex function entry and exit
4610 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4611 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4613 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4614 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4615 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4616 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4617 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4618 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4619 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4621 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4622 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4624 @findex regs_ever_live
4625 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4626 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4627 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4628 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4629 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4630 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4632 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4633 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4634 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4635 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4636 registers are used in the function.
4638 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4639 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4640 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4641 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4642 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4643 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4644 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4646 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4647 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4648 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4649 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4650 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4651 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4652 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4653 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4654 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4655 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4658 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4659 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4660 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4661 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4662 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4665 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4666 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4667 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4668 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4669 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4672 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4673 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4674 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4675 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4676 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4677 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4678 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4679 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4681 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4682 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4683 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4684 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4686 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4687 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4688 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4689 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4690 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4691 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4693 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4694 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4695 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4696 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4697 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4698 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4700 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4701 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4702 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4703 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4705 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4706 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4707 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4708 number of arguments.
4710 @findex current_function_pops_args
4711 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4712 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4713 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4714 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4715 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4720 @findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4721 A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4722 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4723 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4724 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4725 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4726 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4727 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4728 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4729 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4732 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4733 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4734 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4735 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4736 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4740 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4741 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4742 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4743 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4746 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4747 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4748 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4749 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4752 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4753 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4754 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4755 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4756 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4759 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4760 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4761 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4762 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4765 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4766 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4767 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4768 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4771 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4772 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4773 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4774 on entry to an exception edge.
4777 @defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4778 Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4779 instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4780 definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4781 representing the number of delay slots there.
4784 @defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4785 A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4786 slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4788 The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4789 being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4790 eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4791 of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4792 If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4793 may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4794 (at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4797 @findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4798 @findex final_scan_insn
4799 The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4800 list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4801 @code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4802 delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4803 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4804 outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4805 @code{final_scan_insn}.
4807 You need not define this macro if you did not define
4808 @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4811 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4812 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4813 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4814 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4815 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4818 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4819 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4820 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4821 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4822 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4823 all other incoming arguments.
4825 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4826 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4827 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4830 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4833 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4834 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4835 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4836 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4838 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4839 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4840 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4841 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4843 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4844 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4845 some targets, but probably not.
4847 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4848 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4849 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4850 not support varargs.
4853 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4854 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4855 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4856 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4857 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4862 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4863 @cindex profiling, code generation
4865 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4867 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4868 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4869 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4872 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4873 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4874 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4875 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4877 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4878 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4879 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4880 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4883 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4884 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4885 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4886 not support profiling.
4889 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4890 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4891 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4892 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4893 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4894 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4897 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4898 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4899 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4903 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4906 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4907 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4908 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4909 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4911 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4912 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4913 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4914 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4915 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4916 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4919 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4920 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4921 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4922 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4923 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4924 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4925 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4928 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4929 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4930 @cindex stack smashing protection
4932 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4933 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4934 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4935 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4936 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4937 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4939 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4940 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4943 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
4944 This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4945 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4946 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4948 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4949 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4950 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4953 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
4954 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
4958 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4959 @cindex varargs implementation
4961 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4962 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4963 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4964 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4965 conditionals to include it.
4967 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4968 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4969 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4970 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4971 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4972 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4974 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4975 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4978 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4979 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4980 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4981 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4982 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4984 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4985 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4986 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4987 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4989 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4990 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4991 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4992 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4993 to use them for its own purposes.
4994 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4998 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4999 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5000 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5001 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5002 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5003 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5004 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5005 of the current function.
5008 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5009 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5010 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5011 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5012 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5013 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5015 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5016 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5017 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5019 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5020 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5023 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5025 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5026 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5027 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5028 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5029 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5030 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5033 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5034 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5035 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5036 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5037 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5038 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5039 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5040 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5042 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5043 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5044 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5045 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5047 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5048 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5049 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5050 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5051 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5054 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5055 compile time without knowing their data types,
5056 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5057 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5060 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5061 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5062 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5063 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5064 not generate any instructions in this case.
5067 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{ca})
5068 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5069 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5071 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5072 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5073 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5074 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5075 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5076 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5077 except the last are treated as named.
5079 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5082 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{ca})
5083 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5084 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5085 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5086 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5087 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5088 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5092 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5093 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5094 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5096 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5097 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5098 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5099 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5102 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5103 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5104 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5105 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5106 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5107 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5108 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5111 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5112 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5113 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5114 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5115 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5116 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5119 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5120 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5121 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5122 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5123 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5125 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5126 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5127 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5128 to generate it on the spot.
5131 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5132 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5133 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5136 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5137 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5140 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5141 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5143 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5144 is used for aligning trampolines.
5147 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5148 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5149 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5150 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5151 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5154 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5155 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5156 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5157 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5158 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5159 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5161 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5162 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5163 initializing the trampoline proper.
5166 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5167 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5168 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5169 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5170 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5171 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5172 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5173 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5176 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5177 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5178 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5179 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5181 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5182 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5183 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5184 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5185 latter makes initialization faster.
5187 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5188 the following macro.
5190 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5191 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5192 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5193 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5194 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5197 The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
5198 before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
5199 the following macro.
5201 @defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5202 Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
5203 code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
5204 file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
5205 named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
5206 emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
5207 @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT} hook.
5210 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5211 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5212 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5213 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5214 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5216 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5217 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5218 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5219 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5220 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5222 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5223 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5224 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5225 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5226 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5227 special assembler code.
5231 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5232 @cindex library subroutine names
5233 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5235 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5236 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5238 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5239 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5240 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5241 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5242 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5245 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5246 @findex init_one_libfunc
5247 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5248 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5249 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5250 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5251 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5254 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5257 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5258 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5259 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5260 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5261 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5262 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5263 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5266 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5267 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5268 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5269 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5272 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5273 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5274 don't need to define this macro.
5277 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5278 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5279 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5280 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5281 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5282 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5283 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5284 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5287 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5290 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5291 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5292 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5293 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5296 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5297 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5298 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5299 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5300 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5303 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5304 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5305 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5306 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5307 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5308 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5311 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5312 @defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5313 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5314 @code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5315 default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5316 functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5317 systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5320 @cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5321 @defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5322 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5323 and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5324 default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5326 void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5327 void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5328 void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5332 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5333 Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5334 the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5335 involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5336 at once to the method-lookup library function.
5338 The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5339 to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5342 @node Addressing Modes
5343 @section Addressing Modes
5344 @cindex addressing modes
5346 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5347 This is about addressing modes.
5349 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5350 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5351 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5352 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5353 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5354 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5357 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5358 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5359 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5360 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5361 the size of the memory operand.
5364 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5365 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5366 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5367 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5370 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5371 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5372 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5373 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5374 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5375 constant addresses are supported.
5378 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5379 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5380 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5381 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5382 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5383 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5386 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5387 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5388 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5389 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5393 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5394 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5395 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5397 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5398 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5399 desired by the caller.
5401 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5402 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5403 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5404 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5405 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5406 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5407 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5408 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5410 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5411 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5412 register is required.
5414 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5415 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5416 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5417 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5418 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5420 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5421 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5422 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5423 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5424 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5426 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5427 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5428 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5429 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5430 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5431 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5432 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5435 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5436 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5437 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5441 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5445 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5446 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5448 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5449 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5450 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5451 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5452 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5454 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5455 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5458 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5459 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5460 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5461 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5462 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5463 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5464 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5465 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5466 @code{'m'} constraint.
5469 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5470 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5471 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5472 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5473 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5475 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5476 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5478 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5479 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5482 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5483 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5484 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5487 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5488 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5489 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5492 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5493 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5494 should return the new @var{x}.
5496 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5497 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5498 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5499 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5500 strategy can generate better code.
5503 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5504 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5505 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5506 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5507 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5508 performance reasons.
5510 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5511 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5512 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5513 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5514 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5515 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5516 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5519 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5520 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5521 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5522 of reload internals.
5524 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5525 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5526 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5529 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5530 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5531 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5533 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5534 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5535 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5536 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5539 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5540 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5541 the address has become legitimate.
5544 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5545 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5546 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5547 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5548 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5549 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5552 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr})
5553 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5554 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5555 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5558 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5559 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5560 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5561 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5563 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5565 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5568 @defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5569 A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5570 @var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5571 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5572 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5575 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5576 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5577 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5578 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5580 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5582 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5583 @code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5586 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5587 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5588 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5589 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5591 The default definition returns true.
5594 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5595 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5596 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5597 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5598 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5599 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5600 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5601 into their original form.
5604 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5605 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5606 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5609 The default version of this hook returns false.
5611 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5612 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5613 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5614 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5615 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5619 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5620 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5623 The default version returns false for all constants.
5626 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
5627 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5628 the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5629 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5630 when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5631 @var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5632 of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5636 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5637 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5638 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5639 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5640 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5642 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5643 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5644 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5645 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5646 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5647 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5648 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5649 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5650 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5651 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5652 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5654 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5655 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5656 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5657 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5658 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5660 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5661 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5662 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5665 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN (tree @var{x})
5666 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5667 widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5669 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5670 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5671 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5672 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5673 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5676 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD (tree @var{x})
5677 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5678 widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5680 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5681 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5682 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5683 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5684 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5687 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5688 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5689 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5690 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5693 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5694 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5697 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{mask_element_type})
5698 Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5701 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK (tree @var{vec_type}, tree @var{mask})
5702 Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5705 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5706 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5707 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5708 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5709 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5710 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5712 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5713 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5714 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5717 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5718 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5719 vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5720 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5721 The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5722 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5723 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5726 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5727 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5728 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5729 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5730 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5731 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5734 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5735 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5736 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5737 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5738 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5741 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5742 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5743 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5744 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5745 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5748 @node Anchored Addresses
5749 @section Anchored Addresses
5750 @cindex anchored addresses
5751 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5753 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5754 For example, if we have:
5758 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5761 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5762 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5763 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5764 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5770 register int *xr = &x;
5771 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5775 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5776 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5778 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5779 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5780 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5781 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5783 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5784 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5785 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5786 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5787 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5790 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5791 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5792 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5796 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5797 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5798 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5799 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5800 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5802 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5803 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5804 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5805 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5808 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5809 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5810 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5811 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5813 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5814 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5815 or target-specific sections.
5818 @node Condition Code
5819 @section Condition Code Status
5820 @cindex condition code status
5822 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5823 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5825 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5826 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5827 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5828 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5829 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5830 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5833 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5834 the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5835 insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5836 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5837 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5838 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5839 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5840 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5842 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5843 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5844 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5845 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5846 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5847 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5848 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5850 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5851 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5852 interested in most macros in this section.
5855 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5856 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5857 * Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5860 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5861 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5865 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5866 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5867 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5868 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5869 currently based, and several standard flags.
5871 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5872 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5873 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5875 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5876 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5877 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5879 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5882 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5883 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5884 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5885 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5886 define this macro to initialize it.
5888 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5891 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5892 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5893 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5894 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5895 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5898 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5900 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5901 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5902 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5903 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5904 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5905 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5906 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5907 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5908 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5909 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5910 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5911 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5912 condition code value.
5914 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5915 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5916 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5917 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5918 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5919 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5920 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5922 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5923 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5924 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5925 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5928 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5929 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5933 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5934 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5935 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5936 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5937 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5938 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5939 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5940 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5941 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5942 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5943 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5945 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5946 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5947 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5948 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5949 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5950 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5951 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5955 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5957 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5958 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5965 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5966 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5969 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5970 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5971 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5972 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5973 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5974 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5977 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5978 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5981 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5982 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5985 @defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5986 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5987 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5988 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5989 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5991 On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5992 required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5993 and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5994 comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5995 @var{op1} as required.
5997 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5998 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6001 You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
6005 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6006 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6007 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6008 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6009 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6011 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6012 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6013 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6014 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6017 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6021 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6022 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6023 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6024 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6025 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6026 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6027 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6031 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6032 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6033 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6037 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6038 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6039 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6040 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6041 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6042 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6043 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6044 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6045 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6046 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6047 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6049 The default version of this hook returns false.
6052 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode @var{m1}, enum machine_mode @var{m2})
6053 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6054 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6055 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6056 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6057 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6058 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6060 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6061 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6062 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6065 @node Cond Exec Macros
6066 @subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6067 @findex conditional execution
6070 There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6071 supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6072 represent conditional branches.
6074 @defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6075 A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6076 @var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6077 versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6078 predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6079 that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6080 If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6083 #define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6084 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6089 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6090 @cindex costs of instructions
6091 @cindex relative costs
6092 @cindex speed of instructions
6094 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6095 on the target machine.
6097 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6098 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6099 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6100 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6101 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6104 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6105 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6106 registers if they are not general registers.
6108 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6109 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6110 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6111 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6112 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6113 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6115 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6116 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6119 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6120 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6121 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6122 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6123 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6126 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6127 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6128 registers if they are not general registers.
6130 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6131 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6132 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6133 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6134 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6135 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6137 The default version of this function returns 2.
6140 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6141 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6142 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6143 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6144 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6145 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6146 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6148 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6149 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6150 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6151 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6152 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6153 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6155 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6156 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6157 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6158 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6159 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6160 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6161 are the same as to this macro.
6163 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6164 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6167 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6168 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6169 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6170 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6171 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6172 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6173 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6175 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6176 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6177 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6178 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6179 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6180 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6182 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6183 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6184 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6185 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6186 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6187 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6188 are the same as to this target hook.
6191 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6192 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6193 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6194 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6195 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6196 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6197 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6198 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6201 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6202 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6205 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6206 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6207 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6208 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6209 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6210 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6212 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6213 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6214 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6215 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6216 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6217 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6220 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6221 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6222 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6223 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6226 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6227 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6228 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6229 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6230 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6232 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6233 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6234 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6237 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6238 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6239 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6240 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6241 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6243 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6244 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6245 the number of such sequences.
6247 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6248 optimized for speed rather than size.
6250 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6253 @defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6254 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6255 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6256 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6257 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6260 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6261 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6262 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6265 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6266 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6267 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6268 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6269 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6271 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6272 optimized for speed rather than size.
6274 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6277 @defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6278 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6279 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6280 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6281 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6284 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6285 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6286 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6287 a block set insn or a library call.
6288 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6289 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6291 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6292 optimized for speed rather than size.
6294 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6297 @defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6298 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6299 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6300 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6301 storing values other than constant zero.
6302 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6303 than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6306 @defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6307 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6308 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6309 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6310 called with a constant source string.
6311 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6312 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6315 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6316 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6317 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6318 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6321 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6322 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6323 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6324 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6327 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6328 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6329 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6330 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6333 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6334 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6335 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6336 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6339 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6340 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6341 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6342 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6345 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6346 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6347 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6348 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6351 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6352 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6353 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6354 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6357 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6358 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6359 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6360 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6363 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6364 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6365 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6368 @defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6369 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6370 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6371 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6374 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6375 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6377 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6378 available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6379 in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6380 expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6381 @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6383 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6384 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6387 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6388 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6389 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6390 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6391 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6393 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6394 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6395 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6397 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6398 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6401 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, bool @var{speed})
6402 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6403 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6404 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6406 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6407 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6408 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6409 all addresses will have equal costs.
6411 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6412 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6413 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6415 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6416 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6417 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6418 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6419 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6420 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6421 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6422 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6424 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6426 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6427 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6428 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6429 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6430 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6431 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6432 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6433 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6437 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6439 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6440 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6441 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6442 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6444 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6445 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6446 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6447 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6448 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6449 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6450 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6451 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6452 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6453 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6456 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
6457 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6458 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6459 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6460 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6461 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6462 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6463 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6464 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6465 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6466 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6470 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
6471 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6472 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6473 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6474 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6475 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6476 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6477 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6478 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6479 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6480 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6481 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6482 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6485 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6486 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6487 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6488 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6489 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6490 scheduling priorities of insns.
6493 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6494 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6495 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6496 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6497 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6498 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6499 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6500 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6501 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6502 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6503 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6504 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6505 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6506 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6507 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6510 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6511 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6512 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6513 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6514 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6515 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6516 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6517 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6518 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6521 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
6522 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6523 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6524 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6525 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6526 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6527 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6531 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6532 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6533 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6534 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6535 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6536 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6537 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6538 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6541 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6542 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6543 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6544 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6545 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6546 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6547 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6550 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6551 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6552 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6553 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6554 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6557 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6558 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6559 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6560 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6563 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6564 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6565 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6566 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6567 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6568 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6569 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6570 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6573 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6574 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6577 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6578 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6579 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6580 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6583 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6584 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6585 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6588 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6589 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6590 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6591 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6592 state on a single insn is not enough.
6595 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6596 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6597 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6598 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6599 state on a single insn is not enough.
6602 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6603 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6604 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6605 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6606 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6607 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6608 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6609 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6610 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6611 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6612 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6614 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6615 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6616 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6617 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6618 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6619 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6620 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6621 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6622 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6624 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6625 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6626 schedules to choose the best one.
6628 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6631 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx @var{insn})
6633 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6634 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6635 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6638 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6641 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6642 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6646 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx @var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6647 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6650 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6651 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6655 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6656 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6657 round of multipass scheduling.
6660 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6661 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6664 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6665 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6668 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6669 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6670 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6671 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6672 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6673 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6674 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6675 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6676 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6677 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6678 and the current processor cycle.
6681 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6682 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6683 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6684 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6685 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6686 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6687 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6688 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6689 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6690 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6691 and @code{false} otherwise.
6693 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6694 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6695 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6696 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6697 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6698 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6699 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6702 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6703 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6704 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6705 per instruction data structures.
6708 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6709 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6712 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6713 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6714 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6715 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6718 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6719 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6722 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6723 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6726 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6727 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6730 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{request}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6731 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6732 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6733 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6734 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6735 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6736 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6737 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6738 the generated speculative pattern.
6741 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (int @var{dep_status})
6742 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6743 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6744 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6747 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{label}, int @var{mutate_p})
6748 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6749 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6750 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6751 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6752 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6753 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6754 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6755 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6758 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC (const_rtx @var{insn})
6759 This hook is used as a workaround for
6760 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6761 called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6762 discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6763 being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6764 @var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6765 For non-speculative instructions,
6766 the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6767 the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6771 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6772 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6774 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6775 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6778 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6779 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6780 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6781 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6782 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6783 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6784 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6787 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6788 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6789 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6792 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6793 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6794 in its second parameter.
6797 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6798 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6799 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6800 also the latencies of operations.
6804 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6805 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6806 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6808 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6809 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6810 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6811 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6812 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6815 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6816 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6817 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6818 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6819 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6820 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6821 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6823 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6824 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6825 to be string literals.
6827 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6828 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6829 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6830 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6832 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6833 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6834 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6835 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6836 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6837 reuse @code{text_section}.
6839 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6840 if the target does not provide them.
6842 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6843 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6844 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6845 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6848 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6849 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6850 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6851 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6854 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6855 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6856 executed functions in the program.
6859 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6860 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6861 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6862 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6865 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6866 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6867 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6868 initialized, writable small data.
6871 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6872 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6873 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6877 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6878 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6879 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6880 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6881 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
6882 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6883 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6887 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6888 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6889 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6890 uninitialized, writable small data.
6893 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6894 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6895 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6896 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6899 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6900 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6901 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6902 default is @code{'T'}.
6905 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6906 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6907 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6908 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6909 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6910 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6913 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6914 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6915 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6916 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6917 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6918 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6921 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6922 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6923 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6924 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6925 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6926 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6929 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6930 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6931 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6932 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6933 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6934 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6937 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6938 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6939 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6940 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6941 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6942 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6943 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6944 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6945 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6946 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6949 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6950 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6951 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6952 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6953 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6954 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6955 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6956 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6957 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6958 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6959 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6962 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6963 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6964 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6965 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6966 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6969 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6970 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6971 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6972 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6973 readonly data section is used.
6975 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6978 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
6979 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6980 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6981 of its own that you need to create.
6983 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6984 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6988 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
6989 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6990 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6991 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6992 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6994 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6995 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6996 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6997 in read-only sections even in executables.
7000 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7001 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7002 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7003 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7004 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7005 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7006 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7008 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7009 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7011 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7014 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7015 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7016 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7018 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7019 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7020 it is unlikely to be called.
7023 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7024 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7025 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7026 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7027 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7029 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7030 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7031 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7032 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7035 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7036 Return the readonly data section associated with
7037 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7038 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7039 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7040 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7044 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7045 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7046 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7047 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7048 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7051 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7052 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7053 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7056 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7057 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7058 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7059 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7060 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7061 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7062 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7063 returns the @var{id} provided.
7066 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7067 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7068 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7069 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7071 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7072 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7073 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7074 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7075 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7077 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7078 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7079 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7080 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7081 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7084 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7085 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7086 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7087 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7088 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7089 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7091 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7092 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7093 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7094 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7095 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7096 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7098 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7099 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7100 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7101 before overriding it.
7104 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7105 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7106 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7110 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7111 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7112 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7115 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7116 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7117 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7120 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7121 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7123 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7124 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7127 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7128 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7129 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7130 or executable image).
7132 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7133 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7134 currently supported object file formats.
7137 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7138 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7139 The default value is false.
7144 @section Position Independent Code
7145 @cindex position independent code
7148 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7149 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7150 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7151 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7152 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7153 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7154 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7155 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7157 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7158 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7160 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7161 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7162 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7163 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7164 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7165 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7166 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7167 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7168 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7171 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7172 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7173 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7174 the default is zero. Do not define
7175 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7178 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7179 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7180 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7181 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7182 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7183 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7184 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7185 position independent code.
7188 @node Assembler Format
7189 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7191 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7192 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7196 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7197 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7198 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7199 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7200 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7201 and termination routines.
7202 * Macros for Initialization::
7203 Specific macros that control the handling of
7204 initialization and termination routines.
7205 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7206 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7207 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7208 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7211 @node File Framework
7212 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7213 @cindex assembler format
7214 @cindex output of assembler code
7216 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7217 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7219 @findex default_file_start
7220 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7221 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7222 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7223 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7224 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7225 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7226 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7229 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7230 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7231 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7232 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7233 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7234 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7235 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7236 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7238 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7239 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7240 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7243 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7244 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7245 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7246 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7247 this to be done. The default is false.
7250 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7251 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7252 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7255 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7256 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7257 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7258 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7259 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7260 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7264 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7265 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7266 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7270 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7271 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7272 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7276 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7277 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7278 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7279 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7280 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7284 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7285 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7286 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7287 the end of the line.
7291 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7292 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7293 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7294 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7295 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7299 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7300 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7301 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7302 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7305 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7306 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7307 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7308 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7310 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7311 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7314 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7315 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7317 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7320 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7321 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7322 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7323 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7324 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7325 of the filename using this macro.
7328 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7329 A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7330 @samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7331 macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7334 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7335 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7336 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7337 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7338 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7339 this section is associated.
7342 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7343 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7344 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7345 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7346 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7347 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7348 (from static destructors).
7349 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7352 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7353 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7356 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7357 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7358 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7361 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7362 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7363 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7364 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7365 This is true on most ELF targets.
7368 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7369 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7370 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7371 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7372 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7374 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7375 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7376 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7377 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7380 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7381 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7382 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7383 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7384 It can take the following values:
7387 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7388 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7390 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7391 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7392 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7393 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7394 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7395 various different individual optimization passes.
7397 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7398 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7399 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7400 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7401 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7402 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7403 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7404 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7405 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7408 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7409 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7411 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7412 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7415 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7416 supported in the future.
7418 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7419 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7420 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7421 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7422 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7426 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7427 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7428 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7434 @subsection Output of Data
7437 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7438 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7439 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7440 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7441 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7442 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7443 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7444 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7445 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7446 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7447 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7448 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7449 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7450 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7452 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7453 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7454 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7457 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7458 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7459 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7460 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7461 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7462 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7463 split the object into smaller parts.
7465 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7466 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7467 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7470 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7471 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7472 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7473 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7474 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7476 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7477 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7478 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7482 @defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7483 A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7484 @code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7485 @var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7486 allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7488 If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7489 @code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7490 prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7491 @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7494 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7495 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7496 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7497 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7498 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7500 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7501 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7502 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7505 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7506 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7507 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7508 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7511 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7512 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7513 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7514 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7515 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7516 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7517 pool before the function.
7520 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7521 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7522 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7523 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7524 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7525 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7526 immediately after this call.
7528 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7532 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7533 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7534 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7535 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7537 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7538 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7539 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7540 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7541 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7544 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7545 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7546 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7547 Here is how to do this:
7550 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7553 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7554 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7555 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7557 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7560 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7561 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7562 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7563 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7564 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7565 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7567 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7571 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7572 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7573 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7574 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7575 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7577 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7578 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7581 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7582 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7583 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7584 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7585 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7588 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7589 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7591 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7592 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7593 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7594 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7595 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7596 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7597 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7598 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7599 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7600 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7601 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7602 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7603 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7604 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7605 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7606 on the host machine.
7608 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7609 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7613 @node Uninitialized Data
7614 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7616 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7617 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7619 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7620 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7621 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7622 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7623 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7624 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7625 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7626 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7627 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7628 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7629 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7630 an ordinary undefined external.
7632 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7633 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7634 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7636 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7637 common global variables are output.
7640 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7641 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7642 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7643 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7644 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7645 as the number of bits.
7648 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7649 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7650 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7651 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7652 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7653 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7654 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7657 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7658 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7659 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7660 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7661 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7663 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7664 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7665 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7666 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7667 the name, and a newline.
7669 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
7670 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7671 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7672 You do not need to do both.
7674 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7675 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7676 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7677 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7678 common in order to save space in the object file.
7681 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7682 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7683 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7684 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7685 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7687 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7688 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7689 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7691 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7692 static variables are output.
7695 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7696 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7697 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7698 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7699 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7700 as the number of bits.
7703 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7704 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7705 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7706 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7707 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7708 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7709 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7713 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7715 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7716 This is about outputting labels.
7718 @findex assemble_name
7719 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7720 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7721 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7722 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7723 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7724 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7725 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7728 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7729 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7730 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7732 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7733 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7734 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7735 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7737 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7738 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7741 @findex assemble_name_raw
7742 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7743 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7744 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7745 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7746 that it is more efficient.
7750 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7751 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7752 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7753 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7755 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7756 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7757 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7758 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7762 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7763 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7764 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7765 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7766 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7770 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7771 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7772 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7773 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7776 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7777 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7778 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7779 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7780 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7781 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7785 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7786 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7787 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7788 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7790 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7791 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7792 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7793 types at all, do not define this macro.
7796 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7797 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7798 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7799 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7800 the default is not to define this macro.
7802 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7803 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7804 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7805 types at all, do not define this macro.
7808 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7809 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7810 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7811 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7812 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7813 you should not count on this.
7815 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7816 definition of this macro is provided.
7819 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7820 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7821 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7822 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7823 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7824 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7825 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7827 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7828 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7830 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7834 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7835 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7836 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7837 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7838 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7839 representing the function.
7841 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7843 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7847 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7848 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7849 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7850 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7851 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7852 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7854 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7855 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7857 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7858 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7861 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
7862 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7863 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7864 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7865 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7866 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7867 will be an internal label.
7869 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7870 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7872 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7875 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7876 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7877 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7878 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7880 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7884 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7885 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7886 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7887 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7888 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7889 something about the size of the object.
7891 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7894 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7895 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7898 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
7899 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7900 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7901 that is, available for reference from other files.
7903 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7904 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7907 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
7908 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7909 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7910 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7912 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7915 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7916 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7917 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7918 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7919 no other definition is available. Use the expression
7920 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7921 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7922 for making that name weak, and a newline.
7924 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7925 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7929 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7930 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7931 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7932 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7933 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7934 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7935 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7936 to make @var{name} weak.
7939 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7940 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7941 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7942 declaration of @code{name}.
7945 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
7946 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7947 supports weak symbols.
7949 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7950 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
7951 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7954 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7955 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7957 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7958 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7959 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7960 flag such as @option{-melf}.
7963 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7964 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7965 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7966 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7967 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7968 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7969 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7972 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7973 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7976 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7977 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7978 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7979 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7980 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7981 be emitted as one-only.
7984 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
7985 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7986 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7987 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7990 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7991 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7992 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7993 The default is @code{0}.
7995 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7996 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7997 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7998 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7999 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8000 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8001 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8003 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8004 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8005 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8009 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8010 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8011 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8012 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8013 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8016 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8017 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8020 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8021 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8022 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8023 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8026 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8027 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8028 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8029 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8032 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8033 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8034 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8035 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8036 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8037 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8040 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8041 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8044 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8045 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8046 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8047 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8048 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8049 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8052 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8053 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8054 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8055 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8056 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8057 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8058 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8062 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8063 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8064 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8066 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8067 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8068 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8070 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8071 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8072 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8073 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8074 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8076 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8079 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8080 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8081 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8082 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8083 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8084 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8085 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8088 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8092 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8093 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8094 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8096 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8097 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8098 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8100 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8101 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8102 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8103 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8104 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8105 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8106 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8109 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8110 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8111 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8112 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8113 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8115 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8116 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8117 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8118 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8119 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8120 internal static variables in different scopes.
8122 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8123 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8124 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8125 between the name and the number will suffice.
8127 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8128 which is correct for most systems.
8131 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8132 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8133 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8136 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8137 correct for most systems.
8140 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8141 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8142 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8143 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8144 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8145 the tree nodes are available.
8148 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8149 correct for most systems.
8152 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8153 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8154 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8155 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8156 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8157 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8158 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8161 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8162 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8163 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8164 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8165 an undefined weak symbol.
8167 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8168 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8171 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8172 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8173 Objective-C methods.
8175 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8176 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8177 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8180 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8181 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8182 systems define other ways of computing names.
8184 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8185 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8186 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8187 50 characters extra.
8189 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8190 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8191 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8192 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8194 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8195 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8198 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8199 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8200 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8201 Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8202 linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8205 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8206 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8207 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8208 unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8209 whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8212 @node Initialization
8213 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8214 @cindex initialization routines
8215 @cindex termination routines
8216 @cindex constructors, output of
8217 @cindex destructors, output of
8219 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8220 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8221 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8222 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8223 @code{main} is called.
8225 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8226 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8229 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8230 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8231 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8232 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8234 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8235 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8236 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8238 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8239 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8240 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8241 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8242 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8244 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8245 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8246 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8247 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8248 pointer containing zero.
8250 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8251 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8252 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8253 list; destructors in forward order.
8255 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8256 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8257 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8258 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8259 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8260 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8261 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8262 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8264 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8265 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8266 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8267 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8268 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8270 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8271 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8272 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8273 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8274 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8277 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8280 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8281 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8282 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8283 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8284 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8286 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8287 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8288 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8289 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8290 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8291 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8293 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8296 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8297 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8298 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8299 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8300 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8301 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8303 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8304 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8305 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8306 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8307 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8308 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8309 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8310 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8311 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8312 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8313 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8314 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8315 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8316 the initialization process.
8318 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8319 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8320 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8321 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8322 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8323 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8324 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8325 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8326 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8327 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8328 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8331 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8332 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8335 @node Macros for Initialization
8336 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8338 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8339 and termination functions:
8341 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8342 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8343 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8344 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8345 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8346 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8347 run the initialization functions.
8350 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8351 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8352 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8353 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8354 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8357 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8358 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8359 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8362 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8363 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8364 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8367 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8368 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8369 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8370 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8371 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8372 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8374 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8375 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8376 exception tables embedded in the code.
8379 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8380 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8381 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8382 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8383 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8384 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8387 @defmac INVOKE__main
8388 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8389 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8390 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8391 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8394 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8395 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8396 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8397 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8398 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8401 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8402 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8403 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8404 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8407 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8408 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8409 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8411 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8412 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8413 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8414 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8416 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8417 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8418 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8422 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8423 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8424 functions rather than initialization functions.
8427 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8428 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8430 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8431 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8432 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8434 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8435 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8437 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8438 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8439 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8440 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8442 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8443 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8446 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8447 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8448 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8453 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8454 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8455 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8456 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8460 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8461 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8462 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8463 termination functions in shared libraries:
8466 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8467 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8470 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8471 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8472 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8473 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8474 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8475 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8476 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8479 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8480 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8481 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8482 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8483 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8484 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8487 @node Instruction Output
8488 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8490 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8491 This describes assembler instruction output.
8493 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8494 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8495 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8496 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8499 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8500 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8501 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8502 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8503 to registers using alternate names.
8506 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8507 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8508 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8509 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8510 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8511 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8512 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8513 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8515 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8516 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8517 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8518 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8522 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8523 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8524 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8526 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8527 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8528 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8529 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8530 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8531 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8532 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8533 so that it will not be output twice.
8535 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8536 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8537 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8538 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8539 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8541 @findex recog_data.operand
8542 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8543 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8545 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8549 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8550 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8551 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8552 they will be output differently.
8554 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8555 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8556 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8557 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8558 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8559 by changing the contents of the vector.
8561 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8562 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8563 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8564 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8565 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8566 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8568 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8571 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8572 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8573 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8576 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8577 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8578 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8579 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8580 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8581 by checking the contents of the vector.
8584 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8585 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8586 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8589 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8590 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8591 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8592 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8593 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8594 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8595 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8598 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8599 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8600 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8601 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8603 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8604 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8605 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8609 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8610 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8611 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8612 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8613 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8617 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8618 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8619 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8620 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8622 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8623 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8624 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8625 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8626 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8630 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8631 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8632 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8633 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8634 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8635 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8638 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8639 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8640 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8643 @findex final_sequence
8644 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8645 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8646 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8647 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8648 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8652 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8653 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8654 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8655 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8656 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8657 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8658 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8659 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8660 files can define these macros differently.
8663 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8664 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8665 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8666 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8667 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8668 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8669 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8670 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8671 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8672 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8673 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8676 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8677 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8678 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8679 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8682 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8684 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8687 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8688 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8689 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8690 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8691 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8692 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8693 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8695 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8696 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8697 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8699 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8700 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8701 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8702 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8703 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8704 opcodes or operand order.
8707 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8708 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8709 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8710 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8714 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8715 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8716 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8717 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8721 @node Dispatch Tables
8722 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8724 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8725 This concerns dispatch tables.
8727 @cindex dispatch table
8728 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8729 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8730 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8731 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8732 definitions of these labels are output using
8733 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8734 way here. For example,
8737 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8738 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8741 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8742 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8743 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8744 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8745 mode and flags can be read.
8748 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8749 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8750 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8752 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8753 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8754 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8755 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8759 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8763 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8764 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8765 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8766 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8767 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8768 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8770 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8773 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8774 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8777 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8778 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8779 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8780 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8781 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8782 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8783 of the preceding label.
8785 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8789 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8790 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8791 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8792 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8793 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8794 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8795 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8796 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8798 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8801 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
8802 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8803 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8804 to be broken up according to function.
8806 The default is that no label is emitted.
8809 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8810 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8813 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx @var{insn})
8814 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8815 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8816 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8819 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8820 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8823 @node Exception Region Output
8824 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8826 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8828 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8831 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8832 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8833 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8834 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8835 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8837 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8838 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8841 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8842 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8843 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8844 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8845 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8847 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8851 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8852 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8853 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8854 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8855 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8858 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8859 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8860 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8863 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8864 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8865 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8866 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8867 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8868 or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8871 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
8872 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8873 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8874 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8875 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8876 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8877 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8879 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8880 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8881 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8883 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8884 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8885 @var{opts}. In particular, the
8886 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8887 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8888 depending on this setting.
8890 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8891 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8892 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8893 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8894 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
8897 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8898 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8899 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8900 command-line option processing.
8903 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8904 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8905 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8906 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8909 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8910 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8911 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8912 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8913 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8914 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8915 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8918 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8919 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8920 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8921 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8925 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
8926 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8927 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8928 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8929 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8930 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8931 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8934 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
8935 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8936 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8937 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8938 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8939 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8940 @var{address} is the address of the table.
8943 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
8944 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8945 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8946 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8947 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8950 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8951 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8952 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8953 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8954 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8957 @node Alignment Output
8958 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8960 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8961 This describes commands for alignment.
8963 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8964 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8965 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8967 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8968 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8971 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8972 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8973 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8974 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8977 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
8978 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8979 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8980 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8983 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8984 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8987 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8988 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8992 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
8993 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8994 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8995 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8998 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8999 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9000 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
9002 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9003 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9006 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9007 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9008 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9009 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9012 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9013 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9014 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9018 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9019 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9020 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9021 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9023 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9024 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9025 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9026 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9029 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9030 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9031 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9035 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9036 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9037 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9038 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9039 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9042 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9043 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9044 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9045 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9046 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9050 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9051 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9052 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9053 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9056 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9057 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9058 for padding, if necessary.
9061 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9062 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9063 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9064 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9065 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9066 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9070 @node Debugging Info
9071 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9073 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9074 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9077 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9078 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9079 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9080 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9081 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9082 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9086 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9088 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9089 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9091 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9092 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9093 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9094 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9095 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9096 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9097 compiler and another for DBX@.
9099 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9100 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9101 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9102 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9103 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9105 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9106 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9107 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9110 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9111 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9112 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9113 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9114 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9115 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9116 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9117 @option{-g} options is used.
9120 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9121 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9122 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9126 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9127 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9128 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9129 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9130 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9131 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9132 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9134 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9135 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9136 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9137 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9138 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9140 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9141 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9142 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9146 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9148 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9149 These are specific options for DBX output.
9151 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9152 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9153 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9156 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9157 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9158 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9161 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9162 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9163 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9164 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9165 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9166 if there is any occasion to.
9169 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9170 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9171 in the text section.
9174 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9175 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9176 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9177 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9178 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9181 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9182 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9183 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9184 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9185 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9189 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9190 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9191 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9192 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9193 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9196 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9197 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9198 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9199 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9200 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9203 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9204 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9205 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9206 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9207 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9208 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9209 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9210 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9213 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9214 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9215 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9216 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9217 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9218 if backslash is correct for your system.
9221 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9222 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9223 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9227 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9228 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9229 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9232 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9233 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9234 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9235 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9238 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9239 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9240 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9241 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9244 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9245 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9246 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9247 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9250 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9251 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9252 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9253 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9257 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9258 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9259 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9260 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9261 an absolute address.
9264 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9265 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9266 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9267 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9270 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9271 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9272 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9273 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9274 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9275 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9276 number for a type number.
9280 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9282 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9283 These are hooks for DBX format.
9285 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9286 Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9287 information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9288 argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9289 @code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9292 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9293 Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9296 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9297 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9298 output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9301 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9302 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9303 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9304 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9305 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9306 unique labels in the assembly output.
9308 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9309 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9312 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9313 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9314 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9315 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9316 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9319 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9320 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9321 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9322 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9325 @node File Names and DBX
9326 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9328 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9329 This describes file names in DBX format.
9331 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9332 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9333 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9334 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9335 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9337 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9338 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9340 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9341 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9342 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9343 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9346 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9347 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9348 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9349 the beginning of the file.
9352 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9353 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9354 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9355 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9356 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9359 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9360 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9361 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9362 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9364 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9365 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9368 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9369 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9370 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9371 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9372 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9377 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9379 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9380 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9382 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9383 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9384 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9387 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9388 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9389 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9391 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9392 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9393 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9394 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9397 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9398 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9399 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9400 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9401 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9404 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9405 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9406 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9407 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9408 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9409 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9412 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9413 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9414 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9415 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9416 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9418 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9419 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9421 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9422 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9425 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9426 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9427 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9428 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9431 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9432 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9435 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9436 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9437 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9440 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9441 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9442 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9443 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9446 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9447 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9448 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9449 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9452 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9453 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9454 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9457 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9458 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9459 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9460 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9461 is referenced by a function.
9464 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9465 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9466 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9469 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9470 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9471 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9472 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9473 not define them yourself.
9477 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9478 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9479 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9480 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9484 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9485 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9486 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9487 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9491 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9492 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9493 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9494 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9497 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9498 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9499 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9500 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9505 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9507 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9508 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9510 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9511 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9512 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9513 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9514 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9515 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9516 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9519 @node Floating Point
9520 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9521 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9522 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9524 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9525 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9526 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9527 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9528 doing the compilation.
9530 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9531 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9532 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9533 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9534 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9535 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9536 target floating point formats are identical.
9538 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9539 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9540 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9541 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9543 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9544 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9545 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9546 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9550 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9551 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9552 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9553 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9554 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9557 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9558 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9561 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9562 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9565 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9566 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9567 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9570 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9571 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9572 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9573 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9574 defined by the C language for both.
9577 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9578 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9581 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9582 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9585 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9586 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9589 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9590 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9591 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9594 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9595 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9596 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9598 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9599 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9600 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9601 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9604 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9605 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9608 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9609 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9612 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9613 Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9614 return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9615 appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9616 precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9619 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9620 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9621 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9622 integral, it is truncated.
9625 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9626 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9627 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9628 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9631 @node Mode Switching
9632 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9633 @cindex mode switching
9634 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9636 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9637 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9638 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9640 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9641 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9642 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9643 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9644 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9645 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9646 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9648 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9649 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9650 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9651 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9652 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9653 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9654 @code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9658 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9659 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9660 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9661 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9662 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9663 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9664 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9666 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9667 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9668 switch is needed / supplied.
9671 @defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9672 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9673 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9674 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9675 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9676 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9679 @defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9680 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9681 mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9682 different from the incoming mode).
9685 @defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9686 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9687 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9688 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9689 is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9692 @defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9693 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9694 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9695 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9696 is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9699 @defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9700 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
9701 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9702 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9703 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9704 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9705 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9708 @defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9709 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9710 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9711 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9714 @node Target Attributes
9715 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9716 @cindex target attributes
9717 @cindex machine attributes
9718 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9720 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9721 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9722 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9724 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9725 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9726 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9727 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9728 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9732 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9733 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9734 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9735 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9736 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9737 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9740 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
9741 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9742 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9743 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9744 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9745 supposed always to be compatible.
9748 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9749 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9750 the newly defined @var{type}.
9753 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9754 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9755 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9756 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9757 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9758 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9762 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9763 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9764 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9765 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9766 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9767 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9768 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9769 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9771 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9772 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9773 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9774 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9775 will then define a function called
9776 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9777 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9778 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9779 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9780 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9781 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9784 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
9785 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
9788 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9789 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9790 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9791 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9792 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9793 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9794 on this implementation detail.
9797 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9798 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9799 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9800 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9801 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9802 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9803 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9804 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9805 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9806 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9810 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
9812 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9813 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9814 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9815 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9818 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
9819 This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9820 it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9821 options for the current function that might be different than the
9822 options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9823 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9825 The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9826 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9827 @var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9830 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9831 This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9832 in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9834 @xref{Option file format}.
9837 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9838 This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9839 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9840 function specific options.
9843 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9844 This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9845 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9846 function specific options.
9849 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
9850 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9851 set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9852 input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
9853 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9856 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9857 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9858 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9859 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9860 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9862 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9863 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9865 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9866 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9867 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9870 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9871 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9872 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9873 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9874 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9878 @section Emulating TLS
9879 @cindex Emulated TLS
9881 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9882 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9883 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9884 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9885 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9888 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9889 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9890 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9891 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9893 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9894 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9895 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9896 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9899 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9900 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9901 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9902 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9903 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9904 registration function to be used.
9907 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9908 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9909 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9913 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9914 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9915 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9919 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9920 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9921 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9924 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9925 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9926 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9929 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
9930 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9931 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9932 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9933 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9934 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9937 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
9938 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9939 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9940 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9941 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9944 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9945 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9946 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9947 single objects. The default is false.
9950 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9951 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9952 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9955 @node MIPS Coprocessors
9956 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9957 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9959 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9960 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9961 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9962 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9965 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9971 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9972 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9973 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9975 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9976 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9977 later in the function.
9979 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9980 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9981 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9983 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9984 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9986 @defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9987 A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9988 alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9990 @{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9996 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9997 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9999 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10000 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10001 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10002 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10005 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10006 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10007 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10008 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10009 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10011 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10012 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10013 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10014 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10016 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10017 suitable for most targets.
10020 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10021 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10022 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10023 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10024 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10025 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10029 @section C++ ABI parameters
10030 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10032 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10033 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10034 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10035 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10038 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10039 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10040 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10041 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10044 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10045 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10046 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10047 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10048 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10049 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10052 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10053 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10054 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10057 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10058 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10059 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10060 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10061 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10062 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10063 backend's targeted operating system.
10066 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10067 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10068 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10072 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10073 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10074 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10075 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10076 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10077 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10078 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10079 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10082 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10083 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10086 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10087 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10088 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10089 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10090 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10091 unit will not be COMDAT.
10094 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10095 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10096 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10097 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10100 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10101 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10102 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10103 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10106 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10107 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10108 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10109 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10110 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10111 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10114 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10115 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10118 @node Named Address Spaces
10119 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10120 @cindex named address spaces
10122 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10123 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10124 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10125 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10126 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10127 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10128 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10129 @code{const} type attributes.
10131 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10132 pointers to the generic address space.
10134 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10135 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10136 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10137 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10138 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10139 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10140 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10143 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10144 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10147 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10148 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10149 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10150 named address space #1:
10152 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10153 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10156 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10157 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10158 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10159 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10160 generic address space only.
10163 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10164 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10165 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10166 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10167 generic address space only.
10170 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10171 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10172 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10173 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10174 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10175 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10176 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10177 target hooks for the given address space.
10180 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10181 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10182 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10183 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10184 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10185 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10186 explicit named address space support.
10189 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10190 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10191 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10192 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10193 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10196 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{superset}, addr_space_t @var{subset})
10197 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10198 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10199 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10200 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10201 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10202 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10205 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10206 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10207 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10208 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10209 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10210 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10211 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10215 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10216 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10218 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10219 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10221 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10222 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10223 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10224 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10225 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10226 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10227 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10230 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10231 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10232 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10233 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10234 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10235 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10236 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10239 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10240 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10241 elements of a jump-table should have.
10244 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10245 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10246 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10247 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10248 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10249 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10250 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10251 flags can be updated.
10254 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10255 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10256 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10257 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10258 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10262 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10263 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10264 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10265 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10266 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10269 @defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10270 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10271 statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10272 advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10273 of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10274 targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10275 @code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10276 @code{false} otherwise.
10279 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10280 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10281 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10282 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10285 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10286 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10287 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10288 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10289 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10290 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10291 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10292 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10294 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10295 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10296 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10297 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10298 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10300 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10301 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10302 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10303 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10304 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10306 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10307 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10308 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10309 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10312 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10313 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10317 @defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10318 Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10319 point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10323 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10324 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10325 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10326 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10327 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10328 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10329 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10333 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10334 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10337 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10338 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10339 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10340 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10341 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10345 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10346 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10347 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10348 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10349 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10350 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10351 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10352 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10353 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10354 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10355 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10357 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10358 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10359 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10361 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10362 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10363 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10364 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10365 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10367 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10370 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10371 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10372 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10373 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10374 @xref{shift patterns}.
10376 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10377 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10378 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10379 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10380 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10381 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10383 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10384 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10385 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10387 The default implementation of this function returns
10388 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10389 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10390 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10391 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10395 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10396 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10397 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10398 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10399 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10401 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10403 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10404 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10405 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10406 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10407 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10408 such cases may improve things.
10411 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10412 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10413 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10414 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10415 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10416 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10417 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10418 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10419 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10420 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10421 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10423 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10424 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10425 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10426 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10428 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10429 describe two related properties. If you define
10430 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10431 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10434 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10435 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10439 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10440 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10441 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10442 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10443 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10444 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10446 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10447 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10448 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10449 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10450 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10451 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10452 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10453 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10456 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10457 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10458 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10459 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10460 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10461 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10462 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10466 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10470 can be converted to
10473 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10477 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10478 tested into the sign bit.
10480 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10481 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10482 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10483 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10484 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10485 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10487 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10488 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10489 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10494 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10495 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10496 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10497 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10498 combine the normalization with other operations.
10501 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10502 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10506 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10507 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10511 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10514 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10515 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10516 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10517 those cases, e.g., one matching
10520 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10523 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10524 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10525 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10526 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10527 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10528 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10529 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10530 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10532 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10533 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10534 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10537 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10538 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10539 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10540 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10541 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10545 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10546 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10547 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10548 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10549 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10550 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10551 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10552 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10553 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10557 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10558 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10559 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10560 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10561 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10562 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10563 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10564 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10565 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10566 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10569 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10570 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10572 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10573 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10574 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10575 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10577 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10578 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10579 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10580 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10585 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10586 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10587 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10588 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10589 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10591 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10592 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10593 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10597 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10598 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10599 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10600 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10601 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10602 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10603 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10606 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10607 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10608 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10609 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10610 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10611 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10613 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10614 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10615 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10618 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10619 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10620 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10621 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10622 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10627 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10628 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10629 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10630 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10631 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10632 setup required for the pragmas.
10634 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10635 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10636 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10638 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10639 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10641 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10642 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10643 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10646 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10647 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10649 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10650 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10651 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10655 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10658 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10659 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10660 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10661 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10662 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10663 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10664 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10665 arguments of pragmas registered with
10666 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10667 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10669 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10670 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10671 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10672 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10673 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10674 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10675 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10676 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10677 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10678 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10679 how to build this object file.
10682 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10683 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10684 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10687 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10688 True if @code{#pragma extern_prefix} is to be supported.
10691 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10692 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10693 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10694 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10695 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10698 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10699 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10700 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10701 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10702 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10705 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10706 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10707 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10708 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10709 @samp{.} is used instead.
10712 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10713 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10714 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10715 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10716 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10719 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10720 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10721 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10722 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10723 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10724 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10725 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10726 you should define this macro.
10728 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10731 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10732 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10733 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10734 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10735 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10736 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10737 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10738 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10739 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10740 slot of @var{insn}.
10742 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10745 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10746 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10747 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10748 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10749 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10750 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10752 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10755 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
10756 This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10757 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10758 It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10759 clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10760 corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10761 clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10762 @code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10763 for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10766 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10767 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10768 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10769 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10770 separate math library.
10772 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10775 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10776 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10777 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10779 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10783 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10784 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10785 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10786 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10787 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10788 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10789 for cross-profiling.
10792 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10794 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10795 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10796 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10797 1 if it does use cc0.
10800 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10801 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10802 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10803 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10804 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10805 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10806 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10807 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10810 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10811 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10812 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10813 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10814 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10817 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10818 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10819 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10820 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10821 about the currently processed blocks.
10824 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10825 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10826 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10827 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10828 to by @var{ce_info}.
10831 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10832 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10833 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10834 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10835 to by @var{ce_info}.
10838 @defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10839 A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10840 structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10843 @defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10844 If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10845 added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10846 by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10849 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
10850 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10851 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10852 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10854 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10855 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10856 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10857 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10859 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10860 definition is null.
10863 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
10864 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10865 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10868 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10869 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10870 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10871 instructions or prefetch instructions).
10873 To create a built-in function, call the function
10874 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10875 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10876 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
10877 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10878 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10881 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
10882 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10883 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10884 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10885 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10886 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10887 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10888 @code{error_mark_node}.
10891 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
10893 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10894 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10895 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10896 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10897 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10898 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10899 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10903 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
10904 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10905 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10906 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10907 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10908 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10909 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10910 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10911 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10912 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10915 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
10916 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10917 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10918 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10919 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10920 The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10921 call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10924 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const_rtx @var{insn})
10926 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10927 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10928 could not be applied.
10930 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10931 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10932 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10933 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10934 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10937 @defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10939 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10940 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10941 @var{branch2} is possible.
10943 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10944 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10945 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10948 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
10949 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10950 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10951 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10952 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10955 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
10957 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10958 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10959 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10960 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10961 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10962 that had its initial value copied by using
10963 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10964 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10965 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10966 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10968 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10969 it might decide to use another register anyways.
10970 You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10971 that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10972 register in question will not be clobbered.
10973 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10977 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
10978 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10979 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10980 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10981 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10982 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10986 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
10987 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10988 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10989 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10990 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10991 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10992 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10993 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10994 and is returning to processing at the top level.
10995 The default hook function does nothing.
10997 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10998 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10999 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11000 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11001 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11002 outside of any function scope.
11005 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11006 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11007 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11008 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11011 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11012 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11013 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11014 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11018 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11019 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11020 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11021 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11022 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11026 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11027 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11028 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11029 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11030 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11031 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11032 defined as this expression:
11035 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11037 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11042 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11043 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11044 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11045 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11046 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11050 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11052 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11057 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11058 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11059 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11060 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11061 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11062 to inter-block scheduling.
11065 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11066 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11068 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11069 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11070 that all target registers in the class returned by
11071 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11072 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11073 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11074 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11075 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11076 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11079 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11080 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11081 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11082 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11085 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11086 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11087 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11088 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11089 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11090 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11091 number of memory accesses.
11094 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11095 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11096 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11097 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11098 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11099 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11100 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11101 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11104 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11105 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11106 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11107 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11108 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11111 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11112 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11113 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11114 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11115 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11116 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11119 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11120 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11121 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11122 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11123 that are different from @option{-I}.
11126 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11127 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11128 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11129 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11130 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11131 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11134 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11135 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11136 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11137 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11140 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11141 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11142 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11145 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11146 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11147 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11148 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11149 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11152 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11153 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11154 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11157 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11158 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11159 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11160 and scanf formatter settings.
11163 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11164 If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11165 guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11166 main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11167 important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11168 many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11169 ``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11170 and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11173 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11174 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11175 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11176 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11179 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11180 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11181 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11182 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11185 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11186 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11187 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11188 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11189 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11192 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11193 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11194 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11195 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11199 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11200 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11201 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11202 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11203 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11206 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11207 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11208 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11209 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11210 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11213 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11214 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11215 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11216 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11217 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11218 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11219 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11222 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11223 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11224 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11225 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11226 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11228 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11231 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11232 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11233 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11234 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11238 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11239 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11242 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11243 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11244 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11245 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11246 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11249 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11250 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11254 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11255 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11256 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11257 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11261 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11262 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11263 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11264 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11265 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11266 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11267 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11268 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11269 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11272 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11273 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11274 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11275 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11276 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11277 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11278 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11279 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11280 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11281 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11282 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11283 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11284 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11285 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11286 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11287 is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr